Kde se rozmanitost setkává s hodnotou - Katalo.cz

B-SAFE Magneto 3413, pouzdro pro PocketBook 700 ERA, červevné (BSM-PER-3413)

Pouzdro na čtečku knih PocketBook 700 Era, pevné, materiál: plast a umělá kůže, wake/sleep (automatické zapnutí a vypnutí displeje), jemné vnitřní polstrování a ochrana displeje proti poškrábání, červená barva Nosíte čtečku knih všude s sebou a chcete, aby zůstala jako nová? B-SAFE Magneto 3413, pouzdro pro PocketBook 700 ERA, červevné s polstrováním z hladkého materiálu zajistí ochranu před špínou i nechtěnými škrábanci. Jedná se o pevné pouzdro, které bez problému padne do ruky a není tedy důvod k obavám z toho, že by čtečka vypadla. Je ideální volbou pro modely PocketBook, konkrétně 700 Era. Má tedy zachované všechny důležité výřezy pro tlačítka a konektory. Materiálem, který výrobce zvolil pro pouzdro na čtečku knih B-SAFE, je plast a umělá kůže. Co se týče designu, tomuto modelu vládne červená barva. Klíčové znaky pouzdra na čtečku knih B-SAFE Magneto 3413, pouzdro pro PocketBook 700 ERA, červevné Ochrání před vznikem škrábanců a dalších poškození Pevné...

Podívejte se také Meaco DD8L Zambezi (3413)

cena 399.0 Kč
Detail

Cobi 2620 Leopard 2A5 TVM (5902251026202)

Stavebnice - 945 dílků v balení, materiál plast, vhodná od 8 let Jsou vaše děti zapálené do skládání stavebnic? Stavebnice Cobi rozvíjí nejen kreativitu, ale také zručnost nebo jemnou motoriku. Dítka si užijí spoustu zábavy, přičemž ani nepoznají, že se vzdělávají. V balení se nalézá celkem 945 dílků. K jejímu zhotovení byl použitý materiál, jako je plast. Hlavní přednosti stavebnice Cobi 2620 Leopard 2A5 TVM Stavebnice nabízí zábavu i možnost vzdělávání Rozvíjí dětské prstíčky i logické myšlení Ke kompletnímu složení máte k dispozici 945 dílků Materiálem je plast Stavebnice Cobi je přizpůsobena dětem od 8 let

Podívejte se také M-Style SPINE L celokovový pod zrcátko (3413- MS-040155)

cena 1259.0 Kč
Detail

B-save magneto 3413, pouzdro pro Pocketbook 700 era, červené

Stylové magnetické pouzdro pro model PocketBook 700 ERA s důrazem na minimální hmotnost. Elegantní pouzdro s unikátním přichycením díky magnetům přímo ve čtečce. Podpora funkce Wake-up/Sleep při otevření/zavření pouzdra. Typ pouzdra: Pevné pouzdro Materiál pouzdra: Plast, Úmělá kůže Další funkce: Wake/Sleep Magnetické zapínání: Ano

Podívejte se také Jak zvládnout stres a posílit odolnost (978-80-271-3413-7)

cena 359.0 Kč
Detail

Jak zvládnout stres a posílit odolnost (978-80-271-3413-7)

Kniha - autor Dagmar Kožinová, 224 stran, česky, brožovaná bez přebalu lesklá Tato kniha poslouží každému z nás. Stresu se totiž nikdo nevyhne. V našich životech existují situace, které jsou komplikované, zatěžující, a my je potřebujeme zvládnout. Náročné zkoušky v osobním i pracovním životě často prověří nejen naši osobnost, vztahy, odolnost, ale zatíží i zdraví a psychickou pohodu.

Objev podobné jako Jak zvládnout stres a posílit odolnost (978-80-271-3413-7)

cena 310.0 Kč
Detail

Jak zvládnout stres a posílit odolnost (978-80-271-3413-7)

Elektronická kniha - autor Dagmar Kožinová, 224 stran, česky Tato kniha poslouží každému z nás. Stresu se totiž nikdo nevyhne. V našich životech existují situace, které jsou komplikované, zatěžující, a my je potřebujeme zvládnout. Náročné zkoušky v osobním i pracovním životě často prověří nejen naši osobnost, vztahy, odolnost, ale zatíží i zdraví a psychickou pohodu. Autorka v knize uvádí konkrétní situace, ve kterých se můžete ocitnout. Od běžných problémů, každodenních potíží až třeba po dramatické tornádo, které se prohnalo jižní Moravou. Pochopíte díky tomu mnoho zákonitostí stresového prožívání v našem těle, vlastní emoční prožívání i to, co se odehrává v prostoru mysli. V knize najdete řadu doporučení, jak stresové situace zvládat, ale nejen to. Důležité je posílit svou odolnost a mít dostatek energie. Mohou totiž nastat situace, na které se připravit nemůžeme. Vstoupí do našeho života bez pozvání a převrátí ho vzhůru nohama. Vědomou prací na sobě,...

Objev podobné jako Jak zvládnout stres a posílit odolnost (978-80-271-3413-7)

cena 305.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's TVM 5855 pro TV 55-100" (V-TVM5855)

Držák na TV 55" až 100" nástěnný, VESA 200×200, 300×200, 300×300, 400×200, 400×300, 400×400, 600×300 a 600×400, nosnost 75kg, náklon 0°, natočení 180°, montážní sada, systém pro uspořádání kabelů, vodováha a hmoždinky fischer Držák pro televizi Vogel's TVM 5855 pro TV 55-100" je vhodnou vychytávkou do každé domácnosti. Díky němu můžete nápadně opatřit více volného místa ve vašem pokoji. Tento nástěnný držák padne pro televize s úhlopříčkou od 55" do 100". Nejmenší možná vzdálenost držáku od stěny šplhá na 4,5 cm, celkem je možné držák oddálit 69,7 cm od určeného úchytného bodu. Vogel's TVM 5855 pro TV 55-100" je možné s televizí natočit v rozmezí 0°, zásluhou toho si můžete zvolit ideální pozorovací úhel. Televize nesmí přesáhnout maximální povolenou hmotnost držáku samotného, která je v tomto případě 75 kg. V držáku Vogel's je zajištěn systém pro uspořádání kabelů, ten se bude hodit těm, kteří preferují mít v kabelech pořádek. Hned tak budete mít větší přehled.

Objev podobné jako Vogel's TVM 5855 pro TV 55-100" (V-TVM5855)

cena 10490.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's TVM 3243 pro TV 19-43" (V-TVM3243)

Držák na TV 19" až 43" nástěnný, VESA 75×75, 100×100, 100×200, 200×100 a 200×200, nosnost 15kg, náklon +/-10°, natočení 180°, montážní sada, systém pro uspořádání kabelů, vodováha a hmoždinky fischer Držák pro televizi Vogel's TVM 3243 pro TV 19-43" je výbornou vychytávkou. Je vám díky němu umožněno bez obtíží získat mnoho volného místa ve vašem obývacím pokoji. Tento nástěnný držák je přímo určený pro televize s délkou úhlopříček od 19" až 43". Nejmenší možná vzdálenost držáku a stěny činí 6,5 cm, nejvíce je možné držák vzdálit 49,3 cm od zvoleného úchytu. Vogel's TVM 3243 pro TV 19-43" je možné s televizí natočit v rozmezí +/-10°, vlivem toho si můžete zvolit nejvhodnější pozorovací úhel. Vybraná televize nesmí překonat maximální povolenou hmotnost samotného držáku, která je v tomto případě 15 kg. V držáku Vogel's je opatřen systém k uspořádání kabelů, který bude mít úspěch především u těch, kteří mají problém s nepořádkem v kabelech. Vše tak bude mnohem...

Objev podobné jako Vogel's TVM 3243 pro TV 19-43" (V-TVM3243)

cena 2899.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's TVM 3663 pro TV 40-77" (V-TVM3663)

Držák na TV 40" až 77" nástěnný, VESA 200×200, 300×200, 300×300, 400×200, 400×300, 400×400, 600×300 a 600×400, nosnost 35kg, náklon 0 - 20°, natočení 180°, montážní sada, systém pro uspořádání kabelů, vodováha a hmoždinky fischer Držák pro TV Vogel's TVM 3663 pro TV 40-77" je velmi praktickou vychytávkou. Můžete s ním zásadně zajistit prostor v obývacím pokoji. Tento nástěnný držák je vyráběn pro televize s délkou úhlopříček od 40" do 77". Nejmenší vzdálenost držáku a stěny je 5,9 cm, krajně je umožněno držák oddálit 67 cm od určeného úchytného bodu. Vogel's TVM 3663 pro TV 40-77" je možné s televizí natáčet v rozmezí 0 - 20°, vlivem toho je jen na vás najít si vhodný pozorovací úhel. Instalovaná televize nesmí převýšit nejvyšší možnou hmotnost držáku samotného, tudíž 35 kg. V držáku Vogel's je zabudován systém k uspořádání kabelů, ten využijí všichni, kteří mají problém s nepořádkem v kabelech. Přehlednost totiž nebude problém. Tělo držáku je navíc vylepšeno...

Objev podobné jako Vogel's TVM 3663 pro TV 40-77" (V-TVM3663)

cena 5799.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's TVM 3213 pro TV 19-43" (V-TVM3213)

Držák na TV 19" až 43" nástěnný, VESA 75×75, 100×100, 100×200, 200×100 a 200×200, nosnost 15kg, náklon 0 - 20°, montážní sada, vodováha a hmoždinky fischer Držák na TV Vogel's TVM 3213 pro TV 19-43" je skvělou vychytávkou. Je vám díky němu umožněno viditelně opatřit hodně místa v obývacím pokoji. Tento nástěnný držák je dělaný pro televize s úhlopříčkami o délce od 19" do 43". Nejmenší vzdálenost držáku od stěny činí 3,4 cm, nejvíce lze držák oddálit do vzdálenosti 3,4 cm od úchytného bodu. Vogel's TVM 3213 pro TV 19-43" je možné s televizí natočit v rozmezí 0 - 20°, vlivem toho si můžete uzpůsobit vyhovující pozorovací úhel. Vybraná televize nesmí překonat maximální dovolenou hmotnost samotného držáku, což je v této situaci 15 kg. Tělo držáku je navíc zdokonaleno nenápadnou vodováhou, která vám při montáži značně ušetří práci. Za její pomoci totiž připevníte držák absolutně rovně. V balení je zahrnuta montážní sada, s jejíž využitím držák lehce upevníte na...

Objev podobné jako Vogel's TVM 3213 pro TV 19-43" (V-TVM3213)

cena 1089.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's TVM 3223 pro TV 19-43" (V-TVM3223)

Držák na TV 19" až 43" nástěnný, VESA 75×75, 100×100, 100×200, 200×100 a 200×200, nosnost 15kg, náklon +/-10°, natočení 120°, montážní sada, systém pro uspořádání kabelů, vodováha a hmoždinky fischer Držák pro TV Vogel's TVM 3223 pro TV 19-43" si najde své místo v každé domácnosti. S jeho využitím můžete lehce získat volný prostor v obývacím pokoji. Tento nástěnný držák je určený pro televize s úhlopříčkou od 19" po 43". Minimální vzdálenost mezi držákem a zdí je ustanovena na 5,8 cm, naplno můžete držák oddálit do vzdálenosti 30,2 cm od úchytného bodu. Vogel's TVM 3223 pro TV 19-43" je možné s televizí otáčet v rozmezí +/-10°, tudíž budete mít vyhovující pozorovací úhel. Instalovaná televize nesmí převýšit maximální povolenou hmotnost samotného držáku, což je 15 kg. V držáku Vogel's je zastoupen systém na uspořádání kabelů, ten se bude hodit těm, kteří si udržují v kabelech pořádek. Navíc bude vše hned přehlednější. Tělo držáku je navíc vylepšeno drobnou...

Objev podobné jako Vogel's TVM 3223 pro TV 19-43" (V-TVM3223)

cena 2429.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's TVM 3643W pro TV 40-77" (V-TVM3643W)

Držák na TV 40" až 77" nástěnný, VESA 100×100, 200×200, 300×200, 300×300, 400×200, 400×300, 400×400 a 600×400, nosnost 35kg, náklon 0 - 20°, natočení 180°, montážní sada, systém pro uspořádání kabelů, vodováha a hmoždinky fischer Držák pro televizi Vogel's TVM 3643W pro TV 40-77" je skvělou vychytávkou. Dá se s ním snadno uspořit místo v obývacím pokoji. Tento nástěnný držák je určený pro televize s úhlopříčkou od 40" po 77". Minimální vzdálenost držáku a zdi dosahuje 5,9 cm, úplně můžete držák oddálit do vzdálenosti 67 cm od bodu úchytu. Vogel's TVM 3643W pro TV 40-77" je možné s televizí natáčet v rozmezí 0 - 20°, vlivem toho máte jedinečnou možnost si zvolit nejlepší pozorovací úhel. Vybraná televize nesmí překročit maximální možnou hmotnost držáku samotného, to je 35 kg. V držáku Vogel's je zabudován systém pro uspořádání kabelů, za který budou rádi všichni, kterým je nepříjemný nepořádek v kabelech. Vše bude totiž mnohem přehlednější. Tělo držáku je navíc...

Objev podobné jako Vogel's TVM 3643W pro TV 40-77" (V-TVM3643W)

cena 5689.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's TVM 3443W pro TV 32-65" (V-TVM3443W)

Držák na TV 32" až 65" nástěnný, VESA 100×100, 100×200, 200×100, 200×200, 200×300, 300×300, 400×200 a 400×400, nosnost 25kg, náklon 0 - 20°, natočení 180°, montážní sada, systém pro uspořádání kabelů, vodováha a hmoždinky fischer Držák pro TV Vogel's TVM 3443W pro TV 32-65" je velmi praktický výrobek. Jde s ním znatelně opatřit spoustu volného prostoru ve vašem pokoji. Tento nástěnný držák padne pro televize s úhlopříčkami o délce od 32" až 65". Nejmenší možná vzdálenost mezi stěnou a držákem je 5,9 cm, nejvíce můžete držák oddálit 58 cm od bodu úchytu. Vogel's TVM 3443W pro TV 32-65" je možné s televizí natáčet v rozmezí 0 - 20°, zásluhou toho si budete schopni nastavit vhodný pozorovací úhel. Instalovaná televize nesmí překonat nejvyšší dovolenou hmotnost držáku samotného, která je v tomto případě 25 kg. V držáku Vogel's je doplněn systém uspořádání kabelů, za nějž budou rádi všichni, kdo se nechtějí trápit se zamotanými kabely. Budete tak totiž mít ve všem...

Objev podobné jako Vogel's TVM 3443W pro TV 32-65" (V-TVM3443W)

cena 4399.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's TVM 3403 pro TV 32-77" (V-TVM3403)

Držák na TV 32" až 77" nástěnný, VESA 100×100, 100×200, 200×100, 200×200, 200×300, 300×300, 400×200 a 400×400, nosnost 50kg, náklon 0°, montážní sada, vodováha a hmoždinky fischer Držák pro televizi Vogel's TVM 3403 pro TV 32-77" poslouží v každé domácnosti. S jeho pomocí je možné viditelně získat spoustu prostoru v obývacím pokoji. Tento nástěnný držák poslouží pro televize mající délku úhlopříček od 32" po 77". Minimální vzdálenost mezi držákem a zdí je ustanovena na 2,2 cm, celkem lze držák oddálit 2,2 cm od záchytného bodu. Vogel's TVM 3403 pro TV 32-77" je možné s televizí natáčet v rozmezí 0°, tak máte možnost si nastavit nejvhodnější pozorovací úhel. Televize nesmí přesáhnout nejvyšší možnou hmotnost držáku samotného, což je v této situaci 50 kg. Tělo držáku je navíc zdokonaleno šikovnou vodováhou, se kterou montáž zvládnete raz dva. Díky této vychytávce je možné připevnit držák dokonale rovně. Do balení je započítána montážní sada, díky které držák...

Objev podobné jako Vogel's TVM 3403 pro TV 32-77" (V-TVM3403)

cena 1219.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's TVM 1203, fixní TV držák pro obrazovky 19-50", 30 kg

Klíčové vlastnosti: Minimální vzdálenost od stěny - jen 2,2 cm SoftLock™- snadné zajištění vaší TV Vodováha součástí držáku Snadná instalace s aplikací DrillRight™ AR App - vyznačení všech otvorů pro montáž držáku v požadované poloze TV na stěně Hmoždinky Fischer® DuoPower Nástěnný držák na plochý televizor s úhlopříčkou 32-77 palců Hledáte praktický nástěnný držák pro snadné a rychlé upevnění televizoru na stěnu? Sedíte vždy přímo před televizorem, takže se obrazovka nemusí otáčet ani naklánět? Pokud ano, je pro vás tento TV držák z řady QUICK Fixed ideální volbou. Je vhodný pro televizory s úhlopříčkou od 32 do 77 palců a hmotností do 50 kg. Mezi televizorem a stěnou je vzdálenost pouhých 2,2 cm. Rychlá a snadná instalace Nástěnné držáky televizorů QUICK se velmi snadno a rychle instalují díky jedinečnému systému EasyFIX™. Televizor můžete na stěnu připevnit ve třech jednoduchých krocích a užívat si jej již během maximálně 20 minut. Součástí balení je vrtací šablona, šrouby a hmoždinky Fischer® DuoPower. Všechny kroky instalace jsou jasně a stručně vysvětleny v přiloženém rychlém návodu k instalaci. Podrobný návod k použití si můžete prohlédnout také online nebo se podívat na instalační video. S bezplatnou aplikací DrillRight™ AR si snadno vyznačíte první vrtací otvor na stěně. Pak stačí jen přiložit vrtací šablonu. Praktické také je, že váš nástěnný držák televizoru QUICK Fixed má zabudovanou vodováhu. Montáž televizoru do perfektní roviny je proto velmi snadná. Maximální bezpečnost Nástěnné držáky televizorů QUICK vynikají snadnou instalací. Jsou však také nepřekonatelné, pokud jde o bezpečnost. Díky jedinečnému systému SoftLock™ je váš televizor vždy bezpečně zajištěn. Držáky mají navíc certifikát TÜV a jsou testovány na trojnásobek své maximální nosnosti. Vztahuje se na ně pětiletá záruka. Kompletní montážní pokyny

Objev podobné jako Vogel's TVM 1203, fixní TV držák pro obrazovky 19-50", 30 kg

cena 497.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's TVM 1603, fixní TV držák pro obrazovky 40-100", 75 kg

Klíčové vlastnosti: Minimální vzdálenost od stěny - jen 2,2 cm SoftLock™- snadné zajištění vaší TV Vodováha součástí držáku Snadná instalace s aplikací DrillRight™ AR App - vyznačení všech otvorů pro montáž držáku v požadované poloze TV na stěně Hmoždinky Fischer® DuoPower Nástěnný držák pro televizor s úhlopříčkou 40-100 palců Připevnit televizor na zeď snadno a rychle? Tento bezproblémový nástěnný držák televizoru z řady QUICK Fixed je dokonalým řešením. Držák je vhodný pro televizory s úhlopříčkou od 40 do 100 palců a hmotností do 75 kg. Mezi TV a stěnou je vzdálenost pouhých 2,2 cm. Tento držák nelze otáčet ani naklápět. Je proto ideální pro situace, kdy Rychlá a snadná instalace Nástěnné držáky televizorů QUICK jsou navrženy tak, aby montáž televizoru na stěnu byla rychlá a snadná. Instalace pevného nástěnného držáku televizoru QUICK nezabere více než 20 minut. Díky jedinečnému systému EasyFIX™ jste hotovi ve třech jednoduchých krocích. Každý krok je srozumitelně vysvětlen v průvodci rychlou instalací. Pokud byste si raději prohlédli podrobný návod nebo instalační video, můžete tak snadno učinit online. Kromě stručného průvodce instalací balení obsahuje také vrtací šablonu, šrouby a zástrčky Fischer® DuoPower. To znamená, že se můžete ihned pustit do práce. S bezplatnou aplikací DrillRight™ AR si snadno vyznačíte první vrtací otvor na stěně. Pak stačí jen přiložit vrtací šablonu. Praktické také je, že váš nástěnný držák televizoru QUICK Fixed má zabudovanou vodováhu. Montáž televizoru do perfektní roviny je proto velmi snadná. Bezpečná volba S nástěnným držákem televizoru QUICK volíte nejen pohodlí, ale také bezpečnost. Nástěnné držáky televizorů QUICK jsou vybaveny jedinečným systémem SoftLock™, díky kterému je televizor bezpečně zajištěn. Všechny nástěnné držáky televizorů Vogel jsou navíc certifikovány TÜV. Každý výrobek je testován na trojnásobek své maximální nosnosti. Na nástěnný držák televizoru QUICK se vztahuje pětiletá záruka. Kompletní montážní pokyny DrillRight™ AR aplikace pro Android DrillRight™ AR aplikace pro iOS

Objev podobné jako Vogel's TVM 1603, fixní TV držák pro obrazovky 40-100", 75 kg

cena 979.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's W53080 pro TV 40"-65" (W53080)

Držák na TV 40" až 65" nástěnný, VESA 600×400, nosnost 30kg, náklon 20°, natočení 180°, montážní sada a systém pro uspořádání kabelů Kvalitní držák na LCD a LED TV s dvojitým ramenem, které umožňuje náklon a natočení pro ideální pozorovací úhel. Celoživotní záruka, dlouhodobá životnost a precizní zpracování. Jednoduchá manipulace a luxusní vzhled.Chcete ušetřit prostor a zároveň si vystavit vaši novou televizi na jakémkoliv místě vašeho domova? Pak ji nezapomeňte bezpečně připevnit na zeď pomocí tohoto fixního držáku značky VOGELS! Tento držák s dvojitým ramenem zajistí spolehlivé upevnění LCD / LED televizí o velikosti úhlopříčky 40 až 65''. Zabezpečte vaši TV pomocí tohoto držáku s pevnou konstrukcí, který nabízí doživotní záruku! Klíčové vlastnostiFixní držák pro upevnění TV s úhlopříčkou 40 - 65" Elegantní designSpolečně s vaší TV vytváří luxusní...

Objev podobné jako Vogel's W53080 pro TV 40"-65" (W53080)

cena 5989.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's MA3000 pro TV 32-55" (MA3000)

Držák na TV 32" až 55" nástěnný, VESA 100×100 a 400×400, nosnost 60kg, montážní sada Kvalitní držák s pevnou konstrukcí pro bezpečné zavěšení LCD a LED televizí. Šetří prostor a dodává interiéru luxusní vzhled.Chcete ušetřit prostor a zároveň si vystavit vaši novou televizi na jakémkoliv místě vašeho domova? Pak ji nezapomeňte bezpečně připevnit na zeď pomocí tohoto fixního držáku značky VOGELS! Tento držák zajistí spolehlivé upevnění LCD / LED televizí o velikosti úhlopříčky 32 až 55''. Zabezpečte vaši TV pomocí tohoto držáku s pevnou konstrukcí! Klíčové vlastnostiFixní držák pro upevnění TV s úhlopříčkou 32 – 55"Elegantní designSpolečně s vaší TV vytváří luxusní dojemŠetří prostorUniverzální uchycení pro rozteče otvorů (min. 100 × 100 / max. 400 × 400 mm)Pevná a robustní konstrukce s nosností do 60 kgKvalitní materiál Pro vaše pohodlí a útulný domovDíky tomuto...

Objev podobné jako Vogel's MA3000 pro TV 32-55" (MA3000)

cena 499.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's W53081 pro TV 40"-65" (W53081)

Držák na TV 40" až 65" nástěnný, VESA 600×400, nosnost 30kg, náklon 20°, natočení 90°, rotace 180° Kvalitní držák na LCD a LED TV s dvojitým ramenem, které umožňuje náklon a natočení pro ideální pozorovací úhel. Celoživotní záruka, dlouhodobá životnost a precizní zpracování. Jednoduchá manipulace a luxusní vzhled.Chcete ušetřit prostor a zároveň si vystavit vaši novou televizi na jakémkoliv místě vašeho domova? Pak ji nezapomeňte bezpečně připevnit na zeď pomocí tohoto fixního držáku značky VOGELS! Tento držák s dvojitým ramenem zajistí spolehlivé upevnění LCD / LED televizí o velikosti úhlopříčky 40 až 65''. Zabezpečte vaši TV pomocí tohoto držáku s pevnou konstrukcí, který nabízí doživotní záruku! Klíčové vlastnostiFixní držák pro upevnění TV s úhlopříčkou 40 - 65" Elegantní designSpolečně s vaší TV vytváří luxusní dojemMožnost náklonu a natočení pro ideální pozorovací úhel3...

Objev podobné jako Vogel's W53081 pro TV 40"-65" (W53081)

cena 4299.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's W53071 pro TV 32"-55" (W53071)

Držák na TV 32" až 55" nástěnný, VESA 400×400, nosnost 20kg, náklon 20°, natočení 180°, rotace 90° Kvalitní držák na LCD a LED TV s dvojitým ramenem, které umožňuje náklon a natočení pro ideální pozorovací úhel. Celoživotní záruka, dlouhodobá životnost a precizní zpracování. Jednoduchá manipulace a luxusní vzhled.Chcete ušetřit prostor a zároveň si vystavit vaši novou televizi na jakémkoliv místě vašeho domova? Pak ji nezapomeňte bezpečně připevnit na zeď pomocí tohoto fixního držáku značky VOGELS! Tento držák s dvojitým ramenem zajistí spolehlivé upevnění LCD / LED televizí o velikosti úhlopříčky 32 až 55''. Zabezpečte vaši TV pomocí tohoto držáku s pevnou konstrukcí, který nabízí doživotní záruku! Klíčové vlastnostiFixní držák pro upevnění TV s úhlopříčkou 32 - 55" Elegantní designSpolečně s vaší TV vytváří luxusní dojemMožnost náklonu a natočení pro ideální pozorovací úhel3...

Objev podobné jako Vogel's W53071 pro TV 32"-55" (W53071)

cena 3989.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's MA1010 pro TV 17-26" (MA1010)

Držák na TV 17" až 26" nástěnný, VESA 75×75 a 100×100, nosnost 30kg, náklon 15° Kvalitní držák s pevnou konstrukcí pro bezpečné zavěšení LCD a LED televizí. Šetří prostor a dodává interiéru luxusní vzhled. Celoživotní záruka. Lze naklánět.Chcete ušetřit prostor a zároveň si vystavit vaši novou televizi na jakémkoliv místě vašeho domova? Pak ji nezapomeňte bezpečně připevnit na zeď pomocí tohoto fixního držáku značky VOGELS! Tento držák zajistí spolehlivé upevnění LCD / LED televizí o velikosti úhlopříčky 17 až 26''. Zabezpečte vaši TV pomocí tohoto držáku s pevnou konstrukcí, který nabízí doživotní záruku! Klíčové vlastnostiFixní držák pro upevnění TV s úhlopříčkou 17 – 26" Elegantní designSpolečně s vaší TV vytváří luxusní dojemŠetří prostorUniverzální uchycení pro rozteče otvorů (min. 75 × 75 / max. 100 × 100 mm)Lze naklonitPevná a robustní konstrukce s nosností do 30...

Objev podobné jako Vogel's MA1010 pro TV 17-26" (MA1010)

cena 309.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's MA2030 pro TV 19-40" (MA2030)

Držák na TV 19" až 40" nástěnný, VESA 75×75, 100×100, 200×100 a 200×200, nosnost 15kg, náklon 15°, natočení 120°, rotace 60°, montážní sada a systém pro uspořádání kabelů Kvalitní držák na LCD a LED TV umožňuje náklon a natočení pro ideální pozorovací úhel. Celoživotní záruka, dlouhodobá životnost a precizní zpracování. Jednoduchá manipulace a luxusní vzhled.Chcete ušetřit prostor a zároveň si vystavit vaši novou televizi na jakémkoliv místě vašeho domova? Pak ji nezapomeňte bezpečně připevnit na zeď pomocí tohoto fixního držáku značky VOGELS! Tento držák zajistí spolehlivé upevnění LCD / LED televizí o velikosti úhlopříčky 19 až 40''. Zabezpečte vaši TV pomocí tohoto držáku s pevnou konstrukcí, který nabízí doživotní záruku! Klíčové vlastnostiFixní držák pro upevnění TV s úhlopříčkou 19 - 40" Elegantní designSpolečně s vaší TV vytváří luxusní...

Objev podobné jako Vogel's MA2030 pro TV 19-40" (MA2030)

cena 699.0 Kč
Detail

Vogel's W53070 pro TV 32"-55" (W53070)

Držák na TV 32" až 55" nástěnný, VESA 100×100, 200×100, 200×200, 300×200, 300×300, 400×200, 400×300 a 400×400, nosnost 20kg, náklon 20°, natočení 180°, montážní sada Kvalitní držák na LCD a LED TV s dvojitým ramenem, které umožňuje náklon a natočení pro ideální pozorovací úhel. Celoživotní záruka, dlouhodobá životnost a precizní zpracování. Jednoduchá manipulace a luxusní vzhled.Chcete ušetřit prostor a zároveň si vystavit vaši novou televizi na jakémkoliv místě vašeho domova? Pak ji nezapomeňte bezpečně připevnit na zeď pomocí tohoto fixního držáku značky VOGELS! Tento držák s dvojitým ramenem zajistí spolehlivé upevnění LCD / LED televizí o velikosti úhlopříčky 32 až 55''. Zabezpečte vaši TV pomocí tohoto držáku s pevnou konstrukcí, který nabízí doživotní záruku! Klíčové vlastnostiFixní držák pro upevnění TV s úhlopříčkou 32 - 55" Elegantní designSpolečně s vaší TV vytváří luxusní...

Objev podobné jako Vogel's W53070 pro TV 32"-55" (W53070)

cena 4489.0 Kč
Detail

Clatronic HSM/R 3313 zastřihovač

Zastřihovač Clatronic HSM/R 3413 2 v 1. Zastřihovač vlasů a vousů, se kterým se pohodlně a hlavně bezpečně zbavíte nepoddajných vousů či zkrátíte bujnou hřívu. Můžete si zvolit až z pěti délek střihu s nerezovou holící hlavou - 3, 5, 9, 13 a 16 mm. Přístroj disponuje odjímatelným nástavcem, takže holící hlavu je možné velmi snadno a pohodlně vyčistit. Praktický je i LED displej, který signalizuje úroveň nabíjení. Navíc skvěle padne do ruky díky ergonomickému tvaru se speciálním povrchem Soft Touch. K zastřihovači jsou přiloženy nůžky, hřebínek a kartáček pro údržbu holící hlavy. Součástí je i dokovací nabíjecí stanice a adaptér. Baterie: NiMh 800 mAh.

Objev podobné jako Clatronic HSM/R 3313 zastřihovač

cena 509.0 Kč
Detail

HP 17BII+ Financial Calulator - Finanční kalkulačka

RPN a algebraické zadávání dat. HP 17bII+ jednoduše spočítá TVM, amortizaci, hypotéky, IRR, NPV, výnosy obligací, procenta a mnohem více. Statistika dvou proměnných a forecasting. Kalkulátor má vestavěné hodiny a alarm. - 145 x 80 x 16 mm - 110 g Základní popis 3 paměťová tlačítka ne Displej 2 řádky Interní přesnost výpočtů 15 číslic Klávesnice alfanumerická Odlišení proměnných a výsledků na displeji ano Paměť / uživatelsky rozšiřitelná RAM ne Použití volitelné konstatnty při výpočtech ne Registry pro ukládání dat 10 Režim zadávání dat RPN a algebraický Vestavěné funkce přes 250 Obchodní / finanční funkce % změna, % z celku ano Amortizace ano Analýza cash flow ze seznamu Cena a výnos obligace do doby splatnosti ano Cena a výnos obligace k určitému datu ano Časová hodnota peněz (TVM) ano Efektivnost investice (NPV, IRR) ano Funkce cash flow / počet funkcí IRR NVP / okolo 3200 Měnové a jednotkové převody ano NFV, NUS ano Obchodní přirážka vyjádřená procentem z ceny ano Odpisové metody 3 Převody úrokových měr ano Složené úročení ano Statistické/matematické funkce +, -, x, /, %, 1/x, +/-, ln, SQRT x, ex, n!, yx, SUM x, SUM x2, S ano Celkový součet ano Další metody prokládání křivkou ano Lineární regrese ano log, 10x, p, x2 ano Ostatní statistické funkce 7 Prognóza, koeficient korelace ano Standardní odchylka / aritmetický průměr / vážený průměr ano Statistická analýza ze seznamu Správa dat a času Číselné seznamy, editování, třídění, uložení ano Hodiny, kalendář, schůzky a alarm ano Metoda uživatelského nastavení aplikace HP Solve Možnost programování - Řešení rovnic pro kteroukoliv proměnnou bez programování ano Test podmínky 7 Uživatelské menu, uživatelsky definované názvy proměnných ano Velikost paměti mem Výpočty s daty ano Periferie Infračervená tiskárna HP 82240B ano

Objev podobné jako HP 17BII+ Financial Calulator - Finanční kalkulačka

cena 2142.0 Kč
Detail

HP 12c Platinum Financial Calculator - Finanční kalkulačka

Kalkulátor, který se stal de facto standardem ve své třídě má nyní RPN i algebraické zadávání dat. HP 12c platinum má také 4 x více paměti než jeho úspěšný předchůdce HP 12c.Programování série klávesových úhozů - nyní až 400 kroků. Základní popis - 3 paměťová tlačítka ne - Displej 1 řádek - Interní přesnost výpočtů 12 číslic - Klávesnice numerická - Odlišení proměnných a výsledků na displeji ne - Paměť / uživatelsky rozšiřitelná RAM ne - Použití volitelné konstatnty při výpočtech ne - Registry pro ukládání dat 20 - Režim zadávání dat RPN - 129 x 80 x 15 mm - 116 g - Vestavěné funkce 120 Obchodní / finanční funkce % změna, % z celku ano Amortizace ano Analýza cash flow ze seznamu Cena a výnos obligace do doby splatnosti ano Cena a výnos obligace k určitému datu ne Časová hodnota peněz (TVM) ano Efektivnost investice (NPV, IRR) ano Funkce cash flow / počet funkcí IRR NPV / 20 Měnové a jednotkové převody ne NFV, NUS ne Obchodní přirážka vyjádřená procentem z ceny ne Odpisové metody 3 Převody úrokových měr ne Složené úročení ne -------------------------------------------------------------------- Statistické/matematické funkce +, -, x, /, %, 1/x, +/-, ln, SQRT x, ex, n!, yx, SUM x, SUM x2, S ano Celkový součet ano Další metody prokládání křivkou ne Lineární regrese ano log, 10x, p, x2 ne Ostatní statistické funkce 1 Prognóza, koeficient korelace ano Standardní odchylka / aritmetický průměr / vážený průměr ano Statistická analýza kumulativní --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- Správa dat a času Číselné seznamy, editování, třídění, uložení ne Hodiny, kalendář, schůzky a alarm ne Metoda uživatelského nastavení programování posloupností kláves Možnost programování - Řešení rovnic pro kteroukoliv proměnnou bez programování ne Test podmínky 2 Uživatelské menu, uživatelsky definované názvy proměnných ne Velikost paměti 99 kroků Výpočty s daty ano Portugalská verze - návod a obal v portugalštině

Objev podobné jako HP 12c Platinum Financial Calculator - Finanční kalkulačka

cena 1575.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-24P-4X (24xGbE, 4xSFP+, 24xPoE+, 195W)

Cisco switch CBS220-24P-4X Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-24P-4X Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 95,23 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 128 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). Power over Ethernet 802.3af PoE or 802.3at PoE+ delivered over any of the RJ-45 network ports within the listed power budgets PoE Power Budget 195 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 24 Pre-standard PoE Support Cisco Pre-Standard PoE Intelligent PoE power management Support the granular power negotiation with CDP/LLDP communication with PD devices after IEEE classification HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 24 Gigabit Ethernet, 4 10 Gigabit ethernet RJ-45 ports 24 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 10G SFP+ Packet BufferPacket buffer 12 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 257 x 44 mm (17.3 x 10.1 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 4.03 kg (8.88 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=36.9W 220V=37.6W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=248.7W 220V=244.4W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 848.6 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 2 Acoustic noise 25°C: 42.7 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 617232 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-24P-4X (24xGbE, 4xSFP+, 24xPoE+, 195W)

cena 11879.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-24FP-4G (24xGbE, 4xSFP, 24xPoE+, 382W)

Cisco switch CBS220-24FP-4G Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-24FP-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 41,66 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 56 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). Power over Ethernet 802.3af PoE or 802.3at PoE+ delivered over any of the RJ-45 network ports within the listed power budgets PoE Power Budget 382 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 24 Pre-standard PoE Support Cisco Pre-Standard PoE Intelligent PoE power management Support the granular power negotiation with CDP/LLDP communication with PD devices after IEEE classification HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 28 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 24 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 Gigabit Ethernet Small form-factor pluggable (SFP) Packet BufferPacket buffer 4,1 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 257 x 44 mm (17.3 x 10.1 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 4.10 kg (9.04 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=30.8W 220V=30.8W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=459W 220V=445W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 1566.17 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 2 Acoustic noise 25°C: 44.2 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 588411 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-24FP-4G (24xGbE, 4xSFP, 24xPoE+, 382W)

cena 11939.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS250-24PP-4G (24xGbE, 4xSFP, 24xPoE+, 100W, fanless) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS250-24PP-4G - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 250 představuje novou generaci cenově dostupných inteligentních switchů, které kombinují vysoký síťový výkon, zabezpečení a spolehlivost s komplexní sadou síťových funkcí potřebných pro spolehlivou síť malých firem. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS250 Stránky produktu: CBS250-24PP-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity (All switches are wire-speed and nonblocking)Forwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 41,66 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 56 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d spanning tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple spanning tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+); 126 instances are supported Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 4 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad Link Aggregation Group (LAG) VLAN Support for up to 255 active VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers networkwide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain IGMP (versions 1, 2, and 3) snooping Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 255 multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP querier Used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router HOL blocking Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking prevention Loopback detection Provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Layer 3 routingIPv4 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 32 static routes and up to 16 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, LAG, VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for CIDR Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BootP)/DHCP packets SecuritySecure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication, guest VLAN, single/multiple host mode, and single/multiple sessions STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) Secure Core Technology (SCT) Ensures that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plain text or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limit the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS Supports RADIUS authentication for management access. Switch functions as a client. Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DoS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels Access Control Lists (ACLs) Support for up to 512 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, TCP/UDP source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.3 ad LACP, IEEE 802.1D (STP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 Neighbor Discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) version 6 IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, Ping, Traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP), Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS), Syslog, DNS client, DHCP client, DHCP autoconfig IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC 2463): ICMPv6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 Addressing Architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 Specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): Neighbor Discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration RFC 1981: Path MTU Discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 Scoped Address Architecture RFC 3484: Default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: Management Information Base (MIB) IPv6: Textual Conventions and General Group RFC 3595: Textual Conventions for IPv6 Flow Label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, wizards, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Basic and advanced mode for maximum operational efficiency SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP v3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server), to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP Relay, and host name Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfers files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with SCP file download Enables mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable configs Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Automatically applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartports roles to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments. Text view Command-Line Interface (CLI) Scriptable CLI. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI. Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP); cable diagnostics; Ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link is up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables EEE compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 8K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics using Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3at PoE+ and 802.3af PoE delivered over any of the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. Maximum power of 30.0W to any 10/100 or Gigabit Ethernet port, until the PoE budget for the switch is reached. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 100 W Number of ports that support PoE 24 Hardware Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=34.4W 220V=33.11W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=138.9W 220V=138.1W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 476,68 PortsTotal system ports 28 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 24 Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 SFP Console port Cisco Standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer 1,5 MB Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 299 x 44 mm (17.5 x 11.77 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 3.53 kg (7.78 lb) Power 100 to 240V 50 to 60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) Fanless Acoustic noise N/A MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 698220 Warranty Limited lifetime Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 250 Series Smart Switch Power cord Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS250-24PP-4G (24xGbE, 4xSFP, 24xPoE+, 100W, fanless) - REFRESH

cena 4531.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS250-24FP-4X (24xGbE, 4xSFP+, 24xPoE+, 370W) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS250-24FP-4X - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 250 představuje novou generaci cenově dostupných inteligentních switchů, které kombinují vysoký síťový výkon, zabezpečení a spolehlivost s komplexní sadou síťových funkcí potřebných pro spolehlivou síť malých firem. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS250 Stránky produktu: CBS250-24FP-4X Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity (All switches are wire-speed and nonblocking)Forwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 95,23 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 128 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d spanning tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple spanning tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+); 126 instances are supported Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 4 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad Link Aggregation Group (LAG) VLAN Support for up to 255 active VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers networkwide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain IGMP (versions 1, 2, and 3) snooping Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 255 multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP querier Used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router HOL blocking Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking prevention Loopback detection Provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Layer 3 routingIPv4 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 32 static routes and up to 16 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, LAG, VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for CIDR Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BootP)/DHCP packets SecuritySecure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication, guest VLAN, single/multiple host mode, and single/multiple sessions STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) Secure Core Technology (SCT) Ensures that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plain text or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limit the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS Supports RADIUS authentication for management access. Switch functions as a client. Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DoS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels Access Control Lists (ACLs) Support for up to 512 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, TCP/UDP source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.3 ad LACP, IEEE 802.1D (STP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 Neighbor Discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) version 6 IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, Ping, Traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP), Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS), Syslog, DNS client, DHCP client, DHCP autoconfig IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC 2463): ICMPv6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 Addressing Architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 Specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): Neighbor Discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration RFC 1981: Path MTU Discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 Scoped Address Architecture RFC 3484: Default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: Management Information Base (MIB) IPv6: Textual Conventions and General Group RFC 3595: Textual Conventions for IPv6 Flow Label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, wizards, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Basic and advanced mode for maximum operational efficiency SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP v3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server), to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP Relay, and host name Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfers files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with SCP file download Enables mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable configs Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Automatically applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartports roles to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments. Text view Command-Line Interface (CLI) Scriptable CLI. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI. Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP); cable diagnostics; Ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link is up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables EEE compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 8K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics using Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3at PoE+ and 802.3af PoE delivered over any of the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. Maximum power of 30.0W to any 10/100 or Gigabit Ethernet port, until the PoE budget for the switch is reached. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 370 W Number of ports that support PoE 24 Hardware Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=47.14W 220V=47.01W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=451.8W 220V=437.4W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 1543.99 PortsTotal system ports 24 Gigabit Ethernet + 4 10 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 24 Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 SFP+ Console port Cisco Standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer 1,5 MB Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU3M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU5M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 345 x 44 mm (17.5 x 13.59 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 4.6 kg (10.14 lb) Power 100 to 240V 50 to 60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 34.8 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 698220 Warranty Limited lifetime Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 250 Series Smart Switch Power cord Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS250-24FP-4X (24xGbE, 4xSFP+, 24xPoE+, 370W) - REFRESH

cena 7024.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS350-16FP-2G-EU (16xGbE, 2xSFP, 16xPoE+, 240W, fanless) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS350-16FP-2G-EU - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řízené switche řady Cisco Business 350 jsou spolehlivými stavebními prvky pro sítě malých firem. Díky intuitivnímu ovládacímu panelu, pokročilým funkcím a všudypřítomnému zabezpečení urychlují spravované switche řady Cisco Business 350 vaši digitální transformaci. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS350 Stránky produktu: CBS350-16FP-2G-EU Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity and forwarding rate (All switches are wire speed and nonblocking)Capacity in Millions of Packets per Second (mpps) (64-byte packets) 26,78 Switching Capacity in Gigabits per Second (Gbps) 36 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+) and Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation VLAN Support for up to 4,094 VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs; MAC-based VLAN; protocol-based VLAN; IP subnet-based VLAN Management VLAN Private VLAN with promiscuous, isolated, and community port Private VLAN Edge (PVE), also known as protected ports, with multiple uplinks Guest VLAN, unauthenticated VLAN Dynamic VLAN assignment via RADIUS server along with 802.1x client authentication CPE VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers network wide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Multicast TV VLAN Multicast TV VLAN allows the single multicast VLAN to be shared in the network while subscribers remain in separate VLANs. This feature is also known as Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) VLAN Translation Support for VLAN One-to-One Mapping. In VLAN One-to-One Mapping, on an edge interface customer VLANs (C-VLANs) are mapped to service provider VLANs (S-VLANs) and the original C-VLAN tags are replaced by the specified S-VLAN Q-in-Q VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Selective Q-in-Q Selective Q-in-Q is an enhancement to the basic Q-in-Q feature and provides, per edge interface, multiple mappings of different C-VLANs to separate S-VLANs Selective Q-in-Q also allows configuring of Ethertype (Tag Protocol Identifier [TPID]) of the S-VLAN tag Layer 2 protocol tunneling over Q-in-Q is also supported Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP)/Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) enable automatic propagation and configuration of VLANs in a bridged domain Unidirectional Link Detection (UDLD) UDLD monitors physical connection to detect unidirectional links caused by incorrect wiring or cable/port faults to prevent forwarding loops and black holing of traffic in switched networks Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Relay at Layer 2 Relay of DHCP traffic to DHCP server in different VLAN; works with DHCP Option 82 Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) versions 1, 2, and 3 snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 2K multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP Querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router IGMP proxy The IGMP proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on IGMP membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Loopback Detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP Layer 3IPv4 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 990 static routes and up to 128 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 Interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, Link Aggregation (LAG), VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for classless interdomain routing RIP v2 Support for Routing Information Protocol version 2 for dynamic routing Policy-Based Routing (PBR) Flexible routing control to direct packets to different next hop based on IPv4 or IPv6 Access Control List (ACL) DHCP Server Switch functions as an IPv4 DHCP server serving IP addresses for multiple DHCP pools/scopes Support for DHCP options DHCP relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP)/DHCP packets Securityecure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy Protocol (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch IEEE 802.1X (Authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication and accounting, MD5 hash; guest VLAN; unauthenticated VLAN, single/multiple host mode and single/multiple sessions Supports time-based 802.1X; dynamic VLAN assignment; MAC authentication IEEE 802.1X supplicant A switch can be configured to act as a supplicant to another switch. This enables extended secure access in areas outside the wiring closet (such as conference rooms) Web-based authentication Web-based authentication provides network admission control through web browser to any host devices and operating systems STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard A security mechanism to protect the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. This avoids accidental topology loops STP Root Guard This prevents edge devices not in the network administrator’s control from becoming Spanning Tree Protocol root nodes STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) DHCP snooping Filters out DHCP messages with unregistered IP addresses and/or from unexpected or untrusted interfaces. This prevents rogue devices from behaving as DHCP Servers. IP Source Guard (IPSG) When IP Source Guard is enabled at a port, the switch filters out IP packets received from the port if the source IP addresses of the packets have not been statically configured or dynamically learned from DHCP snooping. This prevents IP address spoofing. Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) The switch discards ARP packets from a port if there are no static or dynamic IP/MAC bindings or if there is a discrepancy between the source or destination addresses in the ARP packet. This prevents man-in-the-middle attacks. IP/MAC/Port Binding (IPMB) The preceding features (DHCP Snooping, IP Source Guard, and Dynamic ARP Inspection) work together to prevent DOS attacks in the network, thereby increasing network availability Secure Core Technology (SCT) Makes sure that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plaintext or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user. Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Private VLAN Private VLAN provides security and isolation between switch ports, which helps ensure that users cannot snoop on other users’ traffic; supports multiple uplinks Layer 2 isolation Private VLAN Edge (PVE) PVE (also known as protected ports) provides Layer 2 isolation between devices in the same VLAN, supports multiple uplinks Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limits the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS/TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and TACACS authentication. Switch functions as a client RADIUS accounting The RADIUS accounting functions allow data to be sent at the start and end of services, indicating the amount of resources (such as time, packets, bytes, and so on) used during the session Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DOS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels ACLs Support for up to 1,024 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID, IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol/User Datagram Protocol (TCP/UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported Quality of ServicePriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and remarking ACLs, trusted QoS Queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based; 2R3C policing Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to minimize and prevent global TCP loss synchronization iSCSI traffic optimization A mechanism for giving priority to iSCSI traffic over other types of traffic Standards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ae 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over fiber for LAN, IEEE 802.3an 10GBase-T 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over copper twisted pair cable, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w Rapid STP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol, IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 826, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3176, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode; IPv6 over Ethernet; Dual IPv6/IPv4 stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND); IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration; Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD); ICMP version 6 DHCPv6 stateful client IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) tunnel support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 First Hop Security RA guard ND inspection DHCPv6 guard Neighbor binding table (snooping and static entries) Neighbor binding integrity check Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers MLD proxy The MLD proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on MLD membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, ping, traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), SNMP, RADIUS, syslog, Domain Name System (DNS) client, Telnet Client, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, IPv6 DHCP Relay, Terminal Access Controller Access Control System Plus (TACACS+) IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463): ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration RFC 1981: path MTU discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484: default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: MIB IPv6: textual conventions and general group RFC 3595: textual conventions for IPv6 flow label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports simple and advanced mode, configuration, wizards, customizable dashboard, system maintenance, monitoring, online help, and universal search SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port. Flow-based redirection and mirroring Redirect or mirror traffic to a destination port or mirroring session based on flow Remote Switch Port Analyzer (RSPAN) Traffic can be mirrored across Layer 2 domain to a remote port on a different switch for easier troubleshooting sFlow agent Switch can export sFlow sample to external collectors. sFlow provides visibility into network traffic down to flow level DHCP (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 82, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfer files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with Secure Copy (SCP) file download Enables secure mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartport roles and applies it automatically to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments Textview CLI Scriptable command-line interface. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; SSH; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; BOOTP; SNTP; Xmodem upgrade; cable diagnostics; ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables. EEE Compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 16K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics via Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3af PoE, 802.3at PoE+ or 60W PoE delivered over the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. 60W PoE is also supported on select RJ-45 network ports on select models. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 240 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 16 Hardware Power Consumption (worst case)System power consumption 110V=27.53W 220V=26.68 Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=284W 220V=279.8W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 971.78 PortsTotal system ports 18 x Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 16 x Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 2 x SFP Console port Cisco standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer (All numbers are aggregate across all ports as the buffers are dynamically shared:) 1,5 MB Supported SFP modulesSKU Media MGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP cat 5e GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 268 x 308 x 44 mm (10.56 x 12.14 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 2.49 kg (5.49 lb) Power 100-240V 50-60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) Fanless Acoustic noise N/A MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 706983 Warranty Limited lifetime with next business day advance replacement Package contents Cisco Business 350 Series Managed Switch Power cord Mounting Kit Quick Start Guide Minimum Requirements Web browser: Chrome, Firefox, Edge, Safari Category 5e Ethernet network cable TCP/IP, network adapter, and network operating system (such as Microsoft Windows, Linux, or Mac OS X) installed

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS350-16FP-2G-EU (16xGbE, 2xSFP, 16xPoE+, 240W, fanless) - REFRESH

cena 8551.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS350-24XT-EU (20x10GbE, 4x10GbE/SFP+ combo) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS350-24XT-EU - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řízené switche řady Cisco Business 350 jsou spolehlivými stavebními prvky pro sítě malých firem. Díky intuitivnímu ovládacímu panelu, pokročilým funkcím a všudypřítomnému zabezpečení urychlují spravované switche řady Cisco Business 350 vaši digitální transformaci. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS350 Stránky produktu: CBS350-24XT-EU Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity and forwarding rate (All switches are wire speed and nonblocking)Capacity in Millions of Packets per Second (mpps) (64-byte packets) 240 Switching Capacity in Gigabits per Second (Gbps) 480 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+) and Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation VLAN Support for up to 4,094 VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs; MAC-based VLAN; protocol-based VLAN; IP subnet-based VLAN Management VLAN Private VLAN with promiscuous, isolated, and community port Private VLAN Edge (PVE), also known as protected ports, with multiple uplinks Guest VLAN, unauthenticated VLAN Dynamic VLAN assignment via RADIUS server along with 802.1x client authentication CPE VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers network wide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Multicast TV VLAN Multicast TV VLAN allows the single multicast VLAN to be shared in the network while subscribers remain in separate VLANs. This feature is also known as Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) VLAN Translation Support for VLAN One-to-One Mapping. In VLAN One-to-One Mapping, on an edge interface customer VLANs (C-VLANs) are mapped to service provider VLANs (S-VLANs) and the original C-VLAN tags are replaced by the specified S-VLAN Q-in-Q VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Selective Q-in-Q Selective Q-in-Q is an enhancement to the basic Q-in-Q feature and provides, per edge interface, multiple mappings of different C-VLANs to separate S-VLANs Selective Q-in-Q also allows configuring of Ethertype (Tag Protocol Identifier [TPID]) of the S-VLAN tag Layer 2 protocol tunneling over Q-in-Q is also supported Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP)/Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) enable automatic propagation and configuration of VLANs in a bridged domain Unidirectional Link Detection (UDLD) UDLD monitors physical connection to detect unidirectional links caused by incorrect wiring or cable/port faults to prevent forwarding loops and black holing of traffic in switched networks Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) Relay at Layer 2 Relay of DHCP traffic to DHCP server in different VLAN; works with DHCP Option 82 Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) versions 1, 2, and 3 snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 2K multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP Querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router IGMP proxy The IGMP proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on IGMP membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Loopback Detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP Layer 3IPv4 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 990 static routes and up to 128 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wirespeed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 Interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, Link Aggregation (LAG), VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for classless interdomain routing RIP v2 Support for Routing Information Protocol version 2 for dynamic routing Policy-Based Routing (PBR) Flexible routing control to direct packets to different next hop based on IPv4 or IPv6 Access Control List (ACL) DHCP Server Switch functions as an IPv4 DHCP server serving IP addresses for multiple DHCP pools/scopes Support for DHCP options DHCP relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP)/DHCP packets StackingHardware stacking Up to 4 units in a stack. Up to 200 ports managed as a single system with hardware failover High availability Fast stack failover delivers minimal traffic loss. Support link aggregation across multiple units in a stack Plug-and-play stacking configuration/management Active/standby for resilient stack control Autonumbering Hot swap of units in stack Ring and chain stacking options, auto stacking port speed, flexible stacking port options High-speed stack interconnects Cost-effective high-speed 10G fiber interfaces. Securityecure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy Protocol (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch IEEE 802.1X (Authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication and accounting, MD5 hash; guest VLAN; unauthenticated VLAN, single/multiple host mode and single/multiple sessions Supports time-based 802.1X; dynamic VLAN assignment; MAC authentication IEEE 802.1X supplicant A switch can be configured to act as a supplicant to another switch. This enables extended secure access in areas outside the wiring closet (such as conference rooms) Web-based authentication Web-based authentication provides network admission control through web browser to any host devices and operating systems STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard A security mechanism to protect the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. This avoids accidental topology loops STP Root Guard This prevents edge devices not in the network administrator’s control from becoming Spanning Tree Protocol root nodes STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) DHCP snooping Filters out DHCP messages with unregistered IP addresses and/or from unexpected or untrusted interfaces. This prevents rogue devices from behaving as DHCP Servers. IP Source Guard (IPSG) When IP Source Guard is enabled at a port, the switch filters out IP packets received from the port if the source IP addresses of the packets have not been statically configured or dynamically learned from DHCP snooping. This prevents IP address spoofing. Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) The switch discards ARP packets from a port if there are no static or dynamic IP/MAC bindings or if there is a discrepancy between the source or destination addresses in the ARP packet. This prevents man-in-the-middle attacks. IP/MAC/Port Binding (IPMB) The preceding features (DHCP Snooping, IP Source Guard, and Dynamic ARP Inspection) work together to prevent DOS attacks in the network, thereby increasing network availability Secure Core Technology (SCT) Makes sure that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plaintext or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user. Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Private VLAN Private VLAN provides security and isolation between switch ports, which helps ensure that users cannot snoop on other users’ traffic; supports multiple uplinks Layer 2 isolation Private VLAN Edge (PVE) PVE (also known as protected ports) provides Layer 2 isolation between devices in the same VLAN, supports multiple uplinks Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limits the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS/TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and TACACS authentication. Switch functions as a client RADIUS accounting The RADIUS accounting functions allow data to be sent at the start and end of services, indicating the amount of resources (such as time, packets, bytes, and so on) used during the session Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DOS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels ACLs Support for up to 1,024 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID, IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol/User Datagram Protocol (TCP/UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported Quality of ServicePriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and remarking ACLs, trusted QoS Queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based; 2R3C policing Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to minimize and prevent global TCP loss synchronization iSCSI traffic optimization A mechanism for giving priority to iSCSI traffic over other types of traffic Standards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ae 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over fiber for LAN, IEEE 802.3an 10GBase-T 10 Gbit/s Ethernet over copper twisted pair cable, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w Rapid STP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, IEEE 802.1AB Link Layer Discovery Protocol, IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 826, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3176, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode; IPv6 over Ethernet; Dual IPv6/IPv4 stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND); IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration; Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD); ICMP version 6 DHCPv6 stateful client IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) tunnel support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 First Hop Security RA guard ND inspection DHCPv6 guard Neighbor binding table (snooping and static entries) Neighbor binding integrity check Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers MLD proxy The MLD proxy provides a mechanism for multicast forwarding based on MLD membership information without the need for more complicated multicast routing protocols. IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, ping, traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), SNMP, RADIUS, syslog, Domain Name System (DNS) client, Telnet Client, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, IPv6 DHCP Relay, Terminal Access Controller Access Control System Plus (TACACS+) IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463): ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 stateless address autoconfiguration RFC 1981: path MTU discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484: default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: MIB IPv6: textual conventions and general group RFC 3595: textual conventions for IPv6 flow label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports simple and advanced mode, configuration, wizards, customizable dashboard, system maintenance, monitoring, online help, and universal search SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port. Flow-based redirection and mirroring Redirect or mirror traffic to a destination port or mirroring session based on flow Remote Switch Port Analyzer (RSPAN) Traffic can be mirrored across Layer 2 domain to a remote port on a different switch for easier troubleshooting sFlow agent Switch can export sFlow sample to external collectors. sFlow provides visibility into network traffic down to flow level DHCP (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 82, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfer files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with Secure Copy (SCP) file download Enables secure mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartport roles and applies it automatically to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments Textview CLI Scriptable command-line interface. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; SSH; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; BOOTP; SNTP; Xmodem upgrade; cable diagnostics; ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables. EEE Compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 16K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics via Cisco Discovery Protocol Hardware Power Consumption (worst case)System power consumption 110V=124.1W 220V=124.5 Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 424.8 PortsTotal system ports 20 x 10G copper + 4 x 10G copper/SFP+ combo + 1 x GE OOB management RJ-45 ports 20 x 10G copper Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 x 10G copper/SFP+ combo Console port Cisco standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer (All numbers are aggregate across all ports as the buffers are dynamically shared:) 3 MB Supported SFP modulesSKU Media MGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP cat 5e GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU3M Copper coax SFP-H10GB-CU5M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 350 x 44 mm (17.3 x 13.78 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 5.1 kg (11.2 lb) Power 100-240V 50-60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 32° to 122°F (0° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 4 Acoustic noise 25°C: 41.2 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 556642 Warranty Limited lifetime with next business day advance replacement Package contents Cisco Business 350 Series Managed Switch Power cord Mounting Kit Quick Start Guide Minimum Requirements Web browser: Chrome, Firefox, Edge, Safari Category 5e Ethernet network cable TCP/IP, network adapter, and network operating system (such as Microsoft Windows, Linux, or Mac OS X) installed

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS350-24XT-EU (20x10GbE, 4x10GbE/SFP+ combo) - REFRESH

cena 56610.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP)

Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4G Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-48T-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 74,38 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 52 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 Gigabit Ethernet Small form-factor pluggable (SFP) Packet BufferPacket buffer 12 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 257 x 44 mm (17.3 x 10.1 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 3.18 kg (7.01 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=36.5W 220V=36.1W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 124.54 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 35.0 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 727181 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP)

cena 7916.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-48P-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 382W)

Cisco switch CBS220-48P-4X Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-48P-4X Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 130,94 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 176 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). Power over Ethernet 802.3af PoE or 802.3at PoE+ delivered over any of the RJ-45 network ports within the listed power budgets PoE Power Budget 382 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 48 Pre-standard PoE Support Cisco Pre-Standard PoE Intelligent PoE power management Support the granular power negotiation with CDP/LLDP communication with PD devices after IEEE classification HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet, 4 10 Gigabit ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 10G SFP+ Packet BufferPacket buffer 16 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 350 x 44 mm (17.3 x 13.8 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 5.36 kg (11.82 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=54.8W 220V=55.1W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=482.0W 220V=468.0W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 1644.65 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 35.1 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 265589 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-48P-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+, 48xPoE+, 382W)

cena 17173.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-8FP-E-2G (8xGbE, 2xSFP, 8xPoE+, 130W, fanless) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS220-8FP-E-2G - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-8FP-E-2G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 14,88 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 20 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). Power over Ethernet 802.3af PoE or 802.3at PoE+ delivered over any of the RJ-45 network ports within the listed power budgets. Switches support 802.3af, 802.3at, and Cisco pre-standard (legacy) PoE with maximum power of 30 W per port. PoE Power Budget 130 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 8 Pre-standard PoE Support Cisco Pre-Standard PoE Intelligent PoE power management Support the granular power negotiation with CDP/LLDP communication with PD devices after IEEE classification HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 10 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 8 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 2 Gigabit Ethernet Small form-factor pluggable (SFP) Packet BufferPacket buffer 4,1 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 279 x 170 x 44 mm (11.0 x 6.7 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 1.18 kg (2.60 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, External Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=9.1W 220V=9.1W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=151.4W 220V=148.9W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 516.6 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) Fanless Acoustic noise N/A MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 660457 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-8FP-E-2G (8xGbE, 2xSFP, 8xPoE+, 130W, fanless) - REFRESH

cena 2463.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4G - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-48T-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 74,38 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 52 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 Gigabit Ethernet Small form-factor pluggable (SFP) Packet BufferPacket buffer 12 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 257 x 44 mm (17.3 x 10.1 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 3.18 kg (7.01 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=36.5W 220V=36.1W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 124.54 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 35.0 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 727181 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP) - REFRESH

cena 4927.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS250-8T-E-2G (8xGbE, 2xGbE/SFP combo, fanless) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS250-8T-E-2G - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 250 představuje novou generaci cenově dostupných inteligentních switchů, které kombinují vysoký síťový výkon, zabezpečení a spolehlivost s komplexní sadou síťových funkcí potřebných pro spolehlivou síť malých firem. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS250 Stránky produktu: CBS250-8T-E-2G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity (All switches are wire-speed and nonblocking)Forwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 14,88 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 20 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d spanning tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple spanning tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+); 126 instances are supported Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 4 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad Link Aggregation Group (LAG) VLAN Support for up to 255 active VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers networkwide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain IGMP (versions 1, 2, and 3) snooping Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 255 multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP querier Used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router HOL blocking Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking prevention Loopback detection Provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Layer 3 routingIPv4 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 32 static routes and up to 16 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, LAG, VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for CIDR Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BootP)/DHCP packets SecuritySecure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication, guest VLAN, single/multiple host mode, and single/multiple sessions STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) Secure Core Technology (SCT) Ensures that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plain text or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limit the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS Supports RADIUS authentication for management access. Switch functions as a client. Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DoS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels Access Control Lists (ACLs) Support for up to 512 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, TCP/UDP source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.3 ad LACP, IEEE 802.1D (STP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 Neighbor Discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) version 6 IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, Ping, Traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP), Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS), Syslog, DNS client, DHCP client, DHCP autoconfig IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC 2463): ICMPv6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 Addressing Architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 Specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): Neighbor Discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration RFC 1981: Path MTU Discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 Scoped Address Architecture RFC 3484: Default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: Management Information Base (MIB) IPv6: Textual Conventions and General Group RFC 3595: Textual Conventions for IPv6 Flow Label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, wizards, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Basic and advanced mode for maximum operational efficiency SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP v3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server), to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP Relay, and host name Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfers files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with SCP file download Enables mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable configs Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Automatically applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartports roles to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments. Text view Command-Line Interface (CLI) Scriptable CLI. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI. Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP); cable diagnostics; Ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link is up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables EEE compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 8K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics using Cisco Discovery Protocol Hardware Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=12.55W 220V=12.56W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 42.86 PortsTotal system ports 10 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 8 Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 2 Gigabit Ethernet combo Console port Cisco Standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer 1,5 MB Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 268 x 185 x 44 mm (10.56 x 7.28 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 1.39 kg (3.06 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, External Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) Fanless Acoustic noise N/A MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 2171669 Warranty Limited lifetime Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 250 Series Smart Switch Power cord (power adapter for 8-port SKUs) Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS250-8T-E-2G (8xGbE, 2xGbE/SFP combo, fanless) - REFRESH

cena 2157.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS250-48T-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS250-48T-4G - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 250 představuje novou generaci cenově dostupných inteligentních switchů, které kombinují vysoký síťový výkon, zabezpečení a spolehlivost s komplexní sadou síťových funkcí potřebných pro spolehlivou síť malých firem. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS250 Stránky produktu: CBS250-48T-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity (All switches are wire-speed and nonblocking)Forwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 77,38 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d spanning tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple spanning tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+); 126 instances are supported Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 4 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad Link Aggregation Group (LAG) VLAN Support for up to 255 active VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers networkwide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain IGMP (versions 1, 2, and 3) snooping Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 255 multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP querier Used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router HOL blocking Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking prevention Loopback detection Provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Layer 3 routingIPv4 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 32 static routes and up to 16 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, LAG, VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for CIDR Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BootP)/DHCP packets SecuritySecure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication, guest VLAN, single/multiple host mode, and single/multiple sessions STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) Secure Core Technology (SCT) Ensures that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plain text or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limit the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS Supports RADIUS authentication for management access. Switch functions as a client. Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DoS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels Access Control Lists (ACLs) Support for up to 512 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, TCP/UDP source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.3 ad LACP, IEEE 802.1D (STP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 Neighbor Discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) version 6 IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, Ping, Traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP), Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS), Syslog, DNS client, DHCP client, DHCP autoconfig IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC 2463): ICMPv6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 Addressing Architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 Specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): Neighbor Discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration RFC 1981: Path MTU Discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 Scoped Address Architecture RFC 3484: Default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: Management Information Base (MIB) IPv6: Textual Conventions and General Group RFC 3595: Textual Conventions for IPv6 Flow Label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, wizards, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Basic and advanced mode for maximum operational efficiency SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP v3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server), to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP Relay, and host name Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfers files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with SCP file download Enables mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable configs Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Automatically applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartports roles to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments. Text view Command-Line Interface (CLI) Scriptable CLI. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI. Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP); cable diagnostics; Ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link is up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables EEE compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 8K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics using Cisco Discovery Protocol Hardware Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=48.27W 220V=48.64W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 165.96 PortsTotal system ports 52 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 SFP Console port Cisco Standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer 3 MB Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 288 x 44 mm (17.5 x 11.33 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 3.95 kg (8.71 lb) Power 100 to 240V 50 to 60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C) Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 29.7 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 1452667 Warranty Limited lifetime Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 250 Series Smart Switch Power cord Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS250-48T-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP) - REFRESH

cena 6003.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-16P-2G (16xGbE, 2xSFP, 16xPoE+, 130W, fanless) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS220-16P-2G - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-16P-2G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 26,78 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 36 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). Power over Ethernet 802.3af PoE or 802.3at PoE+ delivered over any of the RJ-45 network ports within the listed power budgets PoE Power Budget 130 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 16 Pre-standard PoE Support Cisco Pre-Standard PoE Intelligent PoE power management Support the granular power negotiation with CDP/LLDP communication with PD devices after IEEE classification HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 18 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 16 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 2 Gigabit Ethernet Small form-factor pluggable (SFP) Packet BufferPacket buffer 4,1 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 203 x 44 mm (17.3 x 8.0 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 3.03 kg (6.68 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=16.8W 220V=18.3W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=160.2W 220V=159.4W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 546.63 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) Fanless Acoustic noise N/A MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 611476 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-16P-2G (16xGbE, 2xSFP, 16xPoE+, 130W, fanless) - REFRESH

cena 3866.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-24FP-4X (24xGbE, 4xSFP+, 24xPoE+, 382W)

Cisco switch CBS220-24FP-4X Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-24FP-4X Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 95,23 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 128 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). Power over Ethernet 802.3af PoE or 802.3at PoE+ delivered over any of the RJ-45 network ports within the listed power budgets PoE Power Budget 382 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 24 Pre-standard PoE Support Cisco Pre-Standard PoE Intelligent PoE power management Support the granular power negotiation with CDP/LLDP communication with PD devices after IEEE classification HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 24 Gigabit Ethernet, 4 10 Gigabit ethernet RJ-45 ports 24 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 10G SFP+ Packet BufferPacket buffer 12 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 257 x 44 mm (17.3 x 10.1 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 4.03 kg (8.88 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=39.6W 220V=39.6W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=470.0W 220V=456.4W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 848.6 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 2 Acoustic noise 25°C: 44.2 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 588411 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-24FP-4X (24xGbE, 4xSFP+, 24xPoE+, 382W)

cena 16749.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-24FP-4X (24xGbE, 4xSFP+, 24xPoE+, 382W) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS220-24FP-4X - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-24FP-4X Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 95,23 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 128 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). Power over Ethernet 802.3af PoE or 802.3at PoE+ delivered over any of the RJ-45 network ports within the listed power budgets PoE Power Budget 382 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 24 Pre-standard PoE Support Cisco Pre-Standard PoE Intelligent PoE power management Support the granular power negotiation with CDP/LLDP communication with PD devices after IEEE classification HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 24 Gigabit Ethernet, 4 10 Gigabit ethernet RJ-45 ports 24 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 10G SFP+ Packet BufferPacket buffer 12 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 257 x 44 mm (17.3 x 10.1 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 4.03 kg (8.88 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=39.6W 220V=39.6W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=470.0W 220V=456.4W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 848.6 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 2 Acoustic noise 25°C: 44.2 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 588411 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-24FP-4X (24xGbE, 4xSFP+, 24xPoE+, 382W) - REFRESH

cena 9597.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-16T-2G (16xGbE, 2xSFP, fanless) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS220-16T-2G - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-16T-2G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 26,78 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 36 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 18 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 16 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 2 Gigabit Ethernet Small form-factor pluggable (SFP) Packet BufferPacket buffer 4,1 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 203 x 44 mm (17.3 x 8.0 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 2.48 kg (5.47 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=11.1W 220V=11.4W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 38.9 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) Fanless Acoustic noise N/A MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 1062289 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-16T-2G (16xGbE, 2xSFP, fanless) - REFRESH

cena 2463.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-24P-4G (24xGbE, 4xSFP, 24xPoE+, 195W) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS220-24P-4G - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-24P-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 41,66 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 56 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). Power over Ethernet 802.3af PoE or 802.3at PoE+ delivered over any of the RJ-45 network ports within the listed power budgets PoE Power Budget 195 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 24 Pre-standard PoE Support Cisco Pre-Standard PoE Intelligent PoE power management Support the granular power negotiation with CDP/LLDP communication with PD devices after IEEE classification HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 28 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 24 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 Gigabit Ethernet Small form-factor pluggable (SFP) Packet BufferPacket buffer 4,1 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 257 x 44 mm (17.3 x 10.1 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 4.07 kg (8.97 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=30.2W 220V=30.4W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=244.3W 220V=240.3W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 833.59 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 2 Acoustic noise 25°C: 42.7 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 587473 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-24P-4G (24xGbE, 4xSFP, 24xPoE+, 195W) - REFRESH

cena 5016.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-24P-4G (24xGbE, 4xSFP, 24xPoE+, 195W)

Cisco switch CBS220-24P-4G Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-24P-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 41,66 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 56 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). Power over Ethernet 802.3af PoE or 802.3at PoE+ delivered over any of the RJ-45 network ports within the listed power budgets PoE Power Budget 195 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 24 Pre-standard PoE Support Cisco Pre-Standard PoE Intelligent PoE power management Support the granular power negotiation with CDP/LLDP communication with PD devices after IEEE classification HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 28 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 24 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 Gigabit Ethernet Small form-factor pluggable (SFP) Packet BufferPacket buffer 4,1 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 257 x 44 mm (17.3 x 10.1 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 4.07 kg (8.97 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=30.2W 220V=30.4W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=244.3W 220V=240.3W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 833.59 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 2 Acoustic noise 25°C: 42.7 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 587473 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-24P-4G (24xGbE, 4xSFP, 24xPoE+, 195W)

cena 8062.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-8P-E-2G (8xGbE, 2xSFP, 8xPoE+, 65W, fanless)

Cisco switch CBS220-8P-E-2G Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-8P-E-2G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 14,88 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 20 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). Power over Ethernet 802.3af PoE or 802.3at PoE+ delivered over any of the RJ-45 network ports within the listed power budgets. Switches support 802.3af, 802.3at, and Cisco pre-standard (legacy) PoE with maximum power of 30 W per port. PoE Power Budget 65 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 8 Pre-standard PoE Support Cisco Pre-Standard PoE Intelligent PoE power management Support the granular power negotiation with CDP/LLDP communication with PD devices after IEEE classification HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 10 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 8 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 2 Gigabit Ethernet Small form-factor pluggable (SFP) Packet BufferPacket buffer 4,1 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 279 x 170 x 44 mm (11.0 x 6.7 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 1.18 kg (2.60 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, External Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=7.8W 220V=8.2W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=81.2W 220V=81.6W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 278.43 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) Fanless Acoustic noise N/A MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 315326 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-8P-E-2G (8xGbE, 2xSFP, 8xPoE+, 65W, fanless)

cena 3048.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-24T-4G (24xGbE, 4xSFP, fanless) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS220-24T-4G - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-24T-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 41,66 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 56 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 28 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 24 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 Gigabit Ethernet Small form-factor pluggable (SFP) Packet BufferPacket buffer 4,1 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 203 x 44 mm (17.3 x 8.0 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 2.75 kg (6.06 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=18.0W 220V=18.0W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 61.42 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) Fanless Acoustic noise N/A MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 1049371 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-24T-4G (24xGbE, 4xSFP, fanless) - REFRESH

cena 2643.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4X - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-48T-4X Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 130,94 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 176 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet, 4 10 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 10G SFP+ Packet BufferPacket buffer 16 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 257 x 44 mm (17.3 x 10.1 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 3.54 kg (7.80 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=41.0W 220V=41.2W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 140.58 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 32,6 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 420827 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+) - REFRESH

cena 7625.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-8FP-E-2G (8xGbE, 2xSFP, 8xPoE+, 130W, fanless)

Cisco switch CBS220-8FP-E-2G Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-8FP-E-2G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 14,88 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 20 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). Power over Ethernet 802.3af PoE or 802.3at PoE+ delivered over any of the RJ-45 network ports within the listed power budgets. Switches support 802.3af, 802.3at, and Cisco pre-standard (legacy) PoE with maximum power of 30 W per port. PoE Power Budget 130 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 8 Pre-standard PoE Support Cisco Pre-Standard PoE Intelligent PoE power management Support the granular power negotiation with CDP/LLDP communication with PD devices after IEEE classification HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 10 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 8 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 2 Gigabit Ethernet Small form-factor pluggable (SFP) Packet BufferPacket buffer 4,1 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 279 x 170 x 44 mm (11.0 x 6.7 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 1.18 kg (2.60 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, External Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=9.1W 220V=9.1W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=151.4W 220V=148.9W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 516.6 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) Fanless Acoustic noise N/A MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 660457 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-8FP-E-2G (8xGbE, 2xSFP, 8xPoE+, 130W, fanless)

cena 4437.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-24T-4X (24xGbE, 4xSFP+) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS220-24T-4X - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-24T-4X Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 95,23 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 128 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 24 Gigabit Ethernet, 4 10 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 24 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 10G SFP+ Packet BufferPacket buffer 12 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 203 x 44 mm (17.3 x 8.0 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 2.69 kg (5.93 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=23.2W 220V=23.6W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 80.5 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 34 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 1372359 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-24T-4X (24xGbE, 4xSFP+) - REFRESH

cena 2714.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+)

Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4X Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-48T-4X Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 130,94 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 176 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet, 4 10 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 10G SFP+ Packet BufferPacket buffer 16 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e SFP-H10GB-CU1M Copper coax SFP-10G-SR Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR Single-mode fiber SFP-10G-SR-S Multimode fiber SFP-10G-LR-S Single-mode fiber EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 257 x 44 mm (17.3 x 10.1 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 3.54 kg (7.80 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=41.0W 220V=41.2W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 140.58 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 32,6 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 420827 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-48T-4X (48xGbE, 4xSFP+)

cena 12256.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS220-48P-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 382W) - REFRESH

Cisco switch CBS220-48P-4G - REFRESH CISCO REFRESH jsou repasované produkty, které společnost CISCO dodává s certifikací kvality, zárukou a servisní podporou odpovídající ekvivalentnímu novému produktu Řada Cisco Business 220 jsou jednoduché a cenově dostupné chytré switche pro sítě podnikové třídy. Díky podpoře mobilních aplikací, nástroji Cisco Business Dashboard a několika možnostem PoE+ poskytuje CBS220 robustní síť v rámci omezeného rozpočtu. Stránky produktu: CBS220-48P-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacityForwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 74,38 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingMAC table Up to 8,192 Media Access Control (MAC) addresses Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d Spanning Tree support, enabled by default Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree [RSTP]) Multiple Spanning Tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP) 16 instances are supported Port grouping Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 8 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad link aggregation Load balance based on source and destination MAC address, or source and destination MAC/IP VLAN Support for up to 256 Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs) simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Auto voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS QinQ VLAN VLANs transparently cross a service provider network while isolating traffic among customers Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking HOL blocking prevention Jumbo frame Frame sizes up to 9,216 supported Loopback detection Loopback detection provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Automatic Media-Dependent Interface Crossover (MDIX) Automatically adjusts transmit and receive pairs if an incorrect cable type (crossover or straight-through) is installed. SecurityACLs Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IP address, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, Transmission Control Protocol (TCP)/ User Datagram Protocol (UDP) source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) packets, TCP flag Support up to 512 rules Port security Creates the ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports; limits the number of learned MAC addresses IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) 802.1X: Remote Authentication Dial-in User Service (RADIUS) authentication; guest VLAN; Single-host, multiple-host, and multisession mode RADIUS, TACACS+ Supports RADIUS and Terminal Access Controller Access Control System (TACACS) authentication; switch functions as a client MAC address filtering Supported Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS protection DOS attack prevention STP Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) Guard This security mechanism protects the network from invalid configurations. A port enabled for BPDU Guard is shut down if a BPDU message is received on that port. Spanning Tree Loop Guard This feature provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops). Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. SCP also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL support: Encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing highly secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues per port Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port-based; 802.1p VLAN priority-based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence, Type of Service (ToS), and DSCP-based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow-based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization. MulticastInternet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Versions 1, 2, and 3 Snooping IGMP limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 256 multicast groups IGMP querier IGMP querier is used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad LACP, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.1D (STP, GARP, and GVRP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, Request for Comments (RFC) 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 922, RFC 920, RFC 950, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1350, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1624, RFC 1700, RFC 1867, RFC 2030, RFC 2616, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 2576, RFC 4330, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1573, RFC 1643, RFC 1757, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2233, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 1157, RFC 1493, RFC 1215, RFC 3416 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 neighbor and router discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) ICMP version 6 IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) Snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, DHCP Client, DHCP Autoconfig, Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP), Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) IPv6 Requests for Comments (RFCs) supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC2463) - ICMP version 6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513) - IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291 - IPv6 addressing architecture RFC 2460 - IPv6 specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461) - Neighbor discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462) - IPv6 stateless address auto-configuration RFC 1981 - Path MTU discovery RFC 4007 - IPv6 scoped address architecture RFC 3484 - Default address selection mechanism ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support direct management with Cisco Business Dashboard and mobile app. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a zero touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Text-editable config files Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Command-line interface Scriptable CLI; a full CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1 and 15 are supported for the CLI SNMP Simple Management Network Protocol (SNMP) versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP version 3 User-based Security Model (USM) Standard Management Information Bases (MIBs) MIB-II (RFC1213) IF-MIB (RFC2863) Bridge-MIB (RFC4188) Bridge-MIB-Extension (RFC2674) RMON (RFC2819) Etherlike MIB (RFC3635) Radius Client MIB (RFC2618) Entity MIB (RFC2737) POWER-ETHERNET-MIB (RFC3621) Syslog MIB (RFC3164) Generic Traps MIB (RFC1215) SNMP-COMMUNITY-MIB SNMP-MIB LLDP-MIB LLDP-EXT-MED-MIB IEEE8023-LAG-MIB CISCO-PORT-SECURITY-MIB CISCO-ENVMON-MIB CISCO-CDP-MIB CISCO-CONFIG-COPY-MIB Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog Remote Monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Port mirroring Traffic on a port or VLAN can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 8 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port. Four sessions are supported. Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP) Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades DHCP (Option 12, 66, 67, 82, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server) to obtain IP address, auto-configuration (with configuration file download), DHCP relay, and hostname Time synchronization Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management HTTP/HTTPS; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Bootstrap Protocol (BOOTP); cable diagnostics; ping; traceroute; syslog DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED Extensions LLDP allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones. Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. Displays brief information for connected Cisco network devices, IP phones, and wireless access points Power efficiencyEEE compliance (802.3az) Support 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet on all ports; substantially reduce the power consumption when link bandwidth is not at full utilization Energy Detect Automatically turns power off on Gigabit Ethernet and 10/100 RJ-45 ports when detecting a link down Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link up Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy. Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy. Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up). Power over Ethernet 802.3af PoE or 802.3at PoE+ delivered over any of the RJ-45 network ports within the listed power budgets PoE Power Budget 382 W Number of Ports That Support PoE 48 Pre-standard PoE Support Cisco Pre-Standard PoE Intelligent PoE power management Support the granular power negotiation with CDP/LLDP communication with PD devices after IEEE classification HardwareButtons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5 or better for 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX; UTP Category 5 Ethernet or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, Speed Flash 64 MB CPU memory 256 MB PortsTotal system ports 52 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Uplink ports 4 Gigabit Ethernet Small form-factor pluggable (SFP) Packet BufferPacket buffer 12 Mb Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 440 x 257 x 44 mm (17.3 x 10.1 x 1.7 in) Unit weight 5.29 kg (11.66 lb) Power 100-240 V, 50-60 Hz, Internal Certifications UL (UL 60950), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A, C-tick Operating temperature 0-50° C Storage temperature –20° C to +70° C Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=52.6W 220V=53.0W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=478.2W 220V=464.0W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 1631.69 Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 34.8 dB MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 452351 Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 220 Series Ethernet switch Power cord or adaptor Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS220-48P-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 382W) - REFRESH

cena 14698.0 Kč
Detail

Cisco switch CBS250-48PP-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 195W)

Cisco switch CBS250-48PP-4G Řada Cisco Business 250 představuje novou generaci cenově dostupných inteligentních switchů, které kombinují vysoký síťový výkon, zabezpečení a spolehlivost s komplexní sadou síťových funkcí potřebných pro spolehlivou síť malých firem. Záruka platná do End of Support 31. 10. 2029. Oznámení End of Life pro CISCO CBS250 Stránky produktu: CBS250-48PP-4G Quick start guide: Quick start guide Switching capacity (All switches are wire-speed and nonblocking)Forwarding rate in millions of packets per second (mpps; 64-byte packets) 77,38 Switching capacity in Gigabits per second (Gbps) 104 Layer 2 switchingSpanning Tree Protocol (STP) Standard 802.1d spanning tree support Fast convergence using 802.1w (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol [RSTP]), enabled by default Multiple spanning tree instances using 802.1s (MSTP); 8 instances are supported Per-VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+); 126 instances are supported Rapid PVST+ (RPVST+); 126 instances are supported Port grouping/link aggregation Support for IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Up to 4 groups Up to 8 ports per group with 16 candidate ports for each (dynamic) 802.3ad Link Aggregation Group (LAG) VLAN Support for up to 255 active VLANs simultaneously Port-based and 802.1Q tag-based VLANs Management VLAN Guest VLAN Voice VLAN Voice traffic is automatically assigned to a voice-specific VLAN and treated with appropriate levels of QoS. Voice Services Discovery Protocol (VSDP) delivers networkwide zero-touch deployment of voice endpoints and call control devices Generic VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Generic Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP) Protocols for automatically propagating and configuring VLANs in a bridged domain IGMP (versions 1, 2, and 3) snooping Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) limits bandwidth-intensive multicast traffic to only the requesters; supports 255 multicast groups (source-specific multicasting is also supported) IGMP querier Used to support a Layer 2 multicast domain of snooping switches in the absence of a multicast router HOL blocking Head-of-Line (HOL) blocking prevention Loopback detection Provides protection against loops by transmitting loop protocol packets out of ports on which loop protection has been enabled. It operates independently of STP. Layer 3 routingIPv4 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv4 packets Up to 32 static routes and up to 16 IP interfaces IPv6 routing Wire-speed routing of IPv6 packets Layer 3 interface Configuration of Layer 3 interface on physical port, LAG, VLAN interface, or loopback interface Classless Interdomain Routing (CIDR) Support for CIDR Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) relay at Layer 3 Relay of DHCP traffic across IP domains User Datagram Protocol (UDP) relay Relay of broadcast information across Layer 3 domains for application discovery or relaying of Bootstrap Protocol (BootP)/DHCP packets SecuritySecure Sockets Layer (SSL) SSL encrypts all HTTPS traffic, allowing secure access to the browser-based management GUI in the switch Secure Shell (SSH) Protocol SSH is a secure replacement for Telnet traffic. Secure Copy (SCP) also uses SSH. SSH v1 and v2 are supported. IEEE 802.1X (authenticator role) Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) authentication, guest VLAN, single/multiple host mode, and single/multiple sessions STP loopback guard Provides additional protection against Layer 2 forwarding loops (STP loops) Secure Core Technology (SCT) Ensures that the switch will receive and process management and protocol traffic no matter how much traffic is received Secure Sensitive Data (SSD) A mechanism to manage sensitive data (such as passwords, keys, and so on) securely on the switch, populating this data to other devices, and secure autoconfig. Access to view the sensitive data as plain text or encrypted is provided according to the user-configured access level and the access method of the user Trustworthy systems Trustworthy systems provide a highly secure foundation for Cisco products Run-time defenses (Executable Space Protection [X-Space], Address Space Layout Randomization [ASLR], Built-In Object Size Checking [BOSC]) Port security Ability to lock source MAC addresses to ports and limit the number of learned MAC addresses RADIUS Supports RADIUS authentication for management access. Switch functions as a client. Storm control Broadcast, multicast, and unknown unicast DoS prevention Denial-of-Service (DoS) attack prevention Multiple user privilege levels in CLI Level 1, 7, and 15 privilege levels Access Control Lists (ACLs) Support for up to 512 rules Drop or rate limit based on source and destination MAC, VLAN ID or IPv4 or IPv6 address, IPv6 flow label, protocol, port, Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)/IP precedence, TCP/UDP source and destination ports, 802.1p priority, Ethernet type, Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets, IGMP packets, TCP flag; ACL can be applied on both ingress and egress sides Time-based ACLs supported QoSPriority levels 8 hardware queues Scheduling Strict priority and Weighted Round-Robin (WRR) queue assignment based on DSCP and class of service (802.1p/CoS) Class of service Port based; 802.1p VLAN priority based; IPv4/v6 IP precedence/Type of Service (ToS)/DSCP based; Differentiated Services (DiffServ); classification and re-marking ACLs, trusted QoS Rate limiting Ingress policer; egress shaping and rate control; per VLAN, per port, and flow based Congestion avoidance A TCP congestion avoidance algorithm is required to reduce and prevent global TCP loss synchronization StandardsStandards IEEE 802.3 10BASE-T Ethernet, IEEE 802.3u 100BASE-TX Fast Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ab 1000BASE-T Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3ad Link Aggregation Control Protocol, IEEE 802.3z Gigabit Ethernet, IEEE 802.3x Flow Control, IEEE 802.3 ad LACP, IEEE 802.1D (STP), IEEE 802.1Q/p VLAN, IEEE 802.1w RSTP, IEEE 802.1s Multiple STP, IEEE 802.1X Port Access Authentication, IEEE 802.3af, IEEE 802.3at, RFC 768, RFC 783, RFC 791, RFC 792, RFC 793, RFC 813, RFC 879, RFC 896, RFC 826, RFC 854, RFC 855, RFC 856, RFC 858, RFC 894, RFC 919, RFC 920, RFC 922, RFC 950, RFC 951, RFC 1042, RFC 1071, RFC 1123, RFC 1141, RFC 1155, RFC 1157, RFC 1213, RFC 1215, RFC 1286, RFC 1350, RFC 1442, RFC 1451, RFC 1493, RFC 1533, RFC 1541, RFC 1542, RFC 1573, RFC 1624, RFC 1643, RFC 1700, RFC 1757, RFC 1867, RFC 1907, RFC 2011, RFC 2012, RFC 2013, RFC 2030, RFC 2131, RFC 2132, RFC 2233, RFC 2576, RFC 2616, RFC 2618, RFC 2665, RFC 2666, RFC 2674, RFC 2737, RFC 2819, RFC 2863, RFC 3164, RFC 3411, RFC 3412, RFC 3413, RFC 3414, RFC 3415, RFC 3416, RFC 4330 IPv6IPv6 IPv6 host mode IPv6 over Ethernet IPv6/IPv4 Dual Stack IPv6 Neighbor Discovery (ND) IPv6 stateless address auto configuration Path Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) discovery Duplicate Address Detection (DAD) Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) version 6 IPv6 over IPv4 network with Intrasite Automatic Tunnel Addressing Protocol (ISATAP) support USGv6 and IPv6 Gold Logo certified IPv6 QoS Prioritize IPv6 packets in hardware IPv6 ACL Drop or rate limit IPv6 packets in hardware Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD v1/2) snooping Deliver IPv6 multicast packets only to the required receivers IPv6 applications Web/SSL, Telnet server/SSH, Ping, Traceroute, Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP), Trivial File Transfer Protocol (TFTP), Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP), Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS), Syslog, DNS client, DHCP client, DHCP autoconfig IPv6 RFCs supported RFC 4443 (which obsoletes RFC 2463): ICMPv6 RFC 4291 (which obsoletes RFC 3513): IPv6 address architecture RFC 4291: IPv6 Addressing Architecture RFC 2460: IPv6 Specification RFC 4861 (which obsoletes RFC 2461): Neighbor Discovery for IPv6 RFC 4862 (which obsoletes RFC 2462): IPv6 Stateless Address Autoconfiguration RFC 1981: Path MTU Discovery RFC 4007: IPv6 Scoped Address Architecture RFC 3484: Default address selection mechanism RFC 5214 (which obsoletes RFC 4214): ISATAP tunneling RFC 4293: Management Information Base (MIB) IPv6: Textual Conventions and General Group RFC 3595: Textual Conventions for IPv6 Flow Label ManagementCisco Business Dashboard Support for embedded probe for Cisco Business Dashboard running on the switch. Eliminates the need to set up a separate hardware or virtual machine for the Cisco Business Dashboard Probe on site. Cisco Business mobile app Mobile app for Cisco Business Switch and Wireless products. Helps to set up a local network in minutes and provide easy management at your fingertips. Cisco Network Plug and Play (PnP) agent The Cisco Network Plug and Play solution provides a simple, secure, unified, and integrated offering to ease new branch or campus device rollouts or for provisioning updates to an existing network. The solution provides a unified approach to provision Cisco routers, switches, and wireless devices with a near-zero-touch deployment experience. Supports Cisco PnP Connect Web user interface Built-in switch configuration utility for easy browser-based device configuration (HTTP/HTTPS). Supports configuration, wizards, system dashboard, system maintenance, and monitoring Basic and advanced mode for maximum operational efficiency SNMP SNMP versions 1, 2c, and 3 with support for traps, and SNMP v3 User-based Security Model (USM) Remote monitoring (RMON) Embedded RMON software agent supports 4 RMON groups (history, statistics, alarms, and events) for enhanced traffic management, monitoring, and analysis IPv4 and IPv6 dual stack Coexistence of both protocol stacks to ease migration Firmware upgrade Web browser upgrade (HTTP/HTTPS) and TFTP and upgrade over SCP running over SSH Dual images for resilient firmware upgrades Port mirroring Traffic on a port can be mirrored to another port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source ports can be mirrored to one destination port VLAN mirroring Traffic from a VLAN can be mirrored to a port for analysis with a network analyzer or RMON probe. Up to 4 source VLANs can be mirrored to one destination port Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) (options 12, 59, 60, 66, 67, 125, 129, and 150) DHCP options facilitate tighter control from a central point (DHCP server), to obtain IP address, autoconfiguration (with configuration and image file download), DHCP Relay, and host name Secure Copy (SCP) Securely transfers files to and from the switch Autoconfiguration with SCP file download Enables mass deployment with protection of sensitive data Text-editable configs Config files can be edited with a text editor and downloaded to another switch, facilitating easier mass deployment Smartports Simplified configuration of QoS and security capabilities Auto Smartports Automatically applies the intelligence delivered through the Smartports roles to the port based on the devices discovered over Cisco Discovery Protocol or LLDP-MED. This facilitates zero-touch deployments. Text view Command-Line Interface (CLI) Scriptable CLI. A full CLI as well as a menu-based CLI is supported. User privilege levels 1, 7, and 15 are supported for the CLI. Localization Localization of GUI and documentation into multiple languages Login banner Configurable multiple banners for web as well as CLI Other management Traceroute; single IP management; HTTP/HTTPS; RADIUS; port mirroring; TFTP upgrade; DHCP client; Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP); cable diagnostics; Ping; syslog; Telnet client (SSH secure support); automatic time settings from Management Station Green (power efficiency)Energy detect Automatically turns power off on RJ-45 port when detecting link down. Active mode is resumed without loss of any packets when the switch detects the link is up Cable length detection Adjusts the signal strength based on the cable length. Reduces the power consumption for shorter cables EEE compliant (802.3az) Supports IEEE 802.3az on all copper Gigabit Ethernet ports Disable port LEDs LEDs can be manually turned off to save on energy Time-based port operation Link up or down based on user-defined schedule (when the port is administratively up) Time-based PoE PoE power can be on or off based on user-defined schedule to save energy GeneralJumbo frames Frame sizes up to 9K bytes. The default MTU is 2K bytes MAC table 8K addresses DiscoveryBonjour The switch advertises itself using the Bonjour protocol Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) (802.1ab) with LLDP-MED extensions Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) allows the switch to advertise its identification, configuration, and capabilities to neighboring devices that store the data in a MIB. LLDP-MED is an enhancement to LLDP that adds the extensions needed for IP phones Cisco Discovery Protocol The switch advertises itself using the Cisco Discovery Protocol. It also learns the connected device and its characteristics using Cisco Discovery Protocol Power over Ethernet802.3at PoE+ and 802.3af PoE delivered over any of the RJ-45 ports within the listed power budgets The following switches support 802.3at PoE+, 802.3af, and Cisco prestandard (legacy) PoE. Maximum power of 30.0W to any 10/100 or Gigabit Ethernet port, until the PoE budget for the switch is reached. The total power available for PoE per switch is as follows: Power dedicated to PoE 195 W Number of ports that support PoE 48 Hardware Power ConsumptionSystem power consumption 110V=68.68W 220V=67.18W Power consumption (with PoE) 110V=276.75W 220V=270.58W Heat dissipation (BTU/hr) 944.31 PortsTotal system ports 52 Gigabit Ethernet RJ-45 ports 48 Gigabit Ethernet Combo ports (RJ-45 + SFP) 4 SFP Console port Cisco Standard RJ45 console port USB slot USB Type-A slot on the front panel of the switch for easy file and image management Buttons Reset button Cabling type Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) Category 5e or better for 1000BASE-T LEDs System, Link/Act, PoE, Speed Flash 256 MB CPU 800 MHz ARM DRAM 512 MB Packet BufferPacket buffer 3 MB Supported SFP ModulesMGBSX1 Multimode fiber MGBLX1 Single-mode fiber MGBLH1 Single-mode fiber MGBT1 UTP Category 5 GLC-SX-MMD Multimode fiber GLC-LH-SMD Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-U Single-mode fiber GLC-BX-D Single-mode fiber GLC-TE UTP cat 5e EnvironmentalUnit dimensions (W x D x H) 445 x 350 x 44 mm (17.5 x 13.78 x 1.73 in) Unit weight 5.43 kg (11.97 lb) Power 100 to 240V 50 to 60 Hz, internal, universal Certifications UL (UL 62368), CSA (CSA 22.2), CE mark, FCC Part 15 (CFR 47) Class A Operating temperature 23° to 122°F (-5° to 50°C Storage temperature -13° to 158°F (-25° to 70°C) Operating humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Storage humidity 10% to 90%, relative, noncondensing Acoustic Noise and Mean Time Between Failure (MTBF)Fan (number) 1 Acoustic noise 25°C: 37.3 dBA MTBF @ 25°C (hours) 1206349 Warranty Limited lifetime Package contentsPackage contents Cisco Business 250 Series Smart Switch Power cord Mounting kit Quick start guide

Objev podobné jako Cisco switch CBS250-48PP-4G (48xGbE, 4xSFP, 48xPoE+, 195W)

cena 15679.0 Kč
Detail